blob: 80500714f427cc8055a75051ff1b2cab970ad682 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000035#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000037#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000038using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000039using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000040
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000041
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000042/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
43/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
44///
45/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
46/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
47/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
48/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
49/// function is being used.
50///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
52/// decls.
53///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000054/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
55/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000056///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000059 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000060 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000061 }
62
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
64 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
67 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000068
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000069 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000070 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
72 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
73 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
74 return true;
75 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000076 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000077
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000078 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000079}
80
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000081/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000082/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000083/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
84///
85void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000087 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000089 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000090
91 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
92 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
94 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000095
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000096 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
97 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000098 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000099 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
100 int isMethod = 0;
101 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
102 // skip over named parameters.
103 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
104 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
105 if (nullPos)
106 --nullPos;
107 else
108 ++i;
109 }
110 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
111 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000113 // skip over named parameters.
114 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
115 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
116 if (nullPos)
117 --nullPos;
118 else
119 ++i;
120 }
121 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000122 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000123 // block or function pointer call.
124 QualType Ty = V->getType();
125 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000126 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000127 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
128 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000129 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
130 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
131 unsigned k;
132 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
133 if (nullPos)
134 --nullPos;
135 else
136 ++i;
137 }
138 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
139 }
140 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
141 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000142 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000143 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000144 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000145 return;
146
147 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 int sentinel = i;
153 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
154 --sentinelPos;
155 ++i;
156 }
157 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
158 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000159 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000160 return;
161 }
162 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
163 ++i;
164 ++sentinel;
165 }
166 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000167 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
168 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
169 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000170 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
172 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
173 return;
174
175 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
176 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
177
178 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
179 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000180}
181
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000182SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
183 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
184 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
185}
186
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000187//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
188// Standard Promotions and Conversions
189//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
192void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
193 QualType Ty = E->getType();
194 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
195
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000196 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000197 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000198 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000199 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
200 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
201 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
202 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
203 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
204 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
205 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000206 //
207 // C++ 4.2p1:
208 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
209 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
210 //
211 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
212 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000213 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000214 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000215 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000216}
217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000220
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221 QualType Ty = E->getType();
222 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
223 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
224 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
225 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
226 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
227 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
228 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
229 // rvalue is T
230 //
231 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000232 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
233 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000234 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000235 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000236 }
237}
238
239
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000240/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
243/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
244/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
245Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
246 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
247 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000248
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000249 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
250 //
251 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
252 // unsigned int may be used:
253 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
254 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
255 // and unsigned int.
256 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
257 //
258 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
259 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
260 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
261 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
263 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000264 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 return Expr;
266 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000268 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000269 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000271 }
272
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000273 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000274 return Expr;
275}
276
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000277/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000279/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
280void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
281 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
282 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000283
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000284 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000285 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
286 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000287 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000288
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000289 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
290}
291
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000292/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
293/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
294/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
295/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000296bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
297 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000299
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
301 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
302 // etc.
303 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
304 return false;
305
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000306 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000307 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
308 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
309 << Expr->getType() << CT))
310 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000311
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000312 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000313 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000314 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
315 << Expr->getType() << CT))
316 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000317
318 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000319}
320
321
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
323/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000324/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
326/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
327/// GCC.
328QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
329 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000330 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000331 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000332
333 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000334
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000335 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000336 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 QualType lhs =
338 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000341
342 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
343 if (lhs == rhs)
344 return lhs;
345
346 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
347 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
348 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
349 return lhs;
350
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000351 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
358
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000359 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000361 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
362 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363 return destType;
364}
365
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
367// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
369
370
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000371/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000372/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
373/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
374/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
375/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000376///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000377ExprResult
Alexis Hunt79eb5462010-08-29 21:26:48 +0000378Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(Scope *S, const Token *StringToks,
379 unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000380 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
381
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000382 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000383 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000384 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000385
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000386 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000387 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
388 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000389
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000390 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000391 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000393
394 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000395 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000397
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000398 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
399 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
400 // strings.
401 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000402 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000403 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000404
Alexis Hunt79eb5462010-08-29 21:26:48 +0000405 StringLiteral *SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
406 Literal.GetStringLength(),
407 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
408 &StringTokLocs[0],
409 StringTokLocs.size());
410
411 if (Literal.isUserDefinedLiteral())
412 return BuildUDStringLiteralExpr(S, SL, Literal.GetNumStringChars(),
413 Literal.getUDSuffix());
414
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000415 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt79eb5462010-08-29 21:26:48 +0000416 return Owned(SL);
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000417}
418
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000419/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
420/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
421/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
422/// for values inside the block or for globals).
423///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000424/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000425/// up-to-date.
426///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000427static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000428 ValueDecl *VD) {
429 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
430 // we wanted to.
431 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
432 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000433
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000434 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
435 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
436 return false;
437
438 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
439 // snapshot it.
440 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
441 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
443 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000444
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000445 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
446 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
447
448 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
449 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
450 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
451 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000452 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
453 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000454
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000455 if (!NextBlock)
456 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000457
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000458 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
459 // having a reference outside it.
460 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
461 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000463 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
464 // a snapshot as well.
465 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
466 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000468 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469}
470
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000471
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000472ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000473Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000474 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
476 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
477}
478
479/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000480ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000481Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
482 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
483 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000484 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000485 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000487 << D->getDeclName();
488 return ExprError();
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000492 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
493 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
494 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000495 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000496 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000497 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
498 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000499 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
500 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000501 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000502 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000503 << D->getIdentifier();
504 return ExprError();
505 }
506 }
507 }
508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000510 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000511
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000512 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
513 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
514 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000515 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000516}
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
519/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
520/// actual member.
521///
522/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
523/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
524/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
525/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
526/// we found.
527///
528/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
529/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
530/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
531VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
532 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
534 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
535 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
536
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000538 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
539 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
540 do {
541 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000542 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000543 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000545 else {
546 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
547 break;
548 }
549 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000551 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552
553 return BaseObject;
554}
555
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000556ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000557Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
558 FieldDecl *Field,
559 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
560 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
561 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000562 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000563 AnonFields);
564
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000565 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
566 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
567 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
568 // found via name lookup.
569 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000571 if (BaseObject) {
572 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
573 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000574 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000575 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000576 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000577 BaseQuals
578 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
580 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
581 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
582 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
583 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000584 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
586 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
587 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000588 BaseQuals
589 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 } else {
591 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
592 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
593 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000594 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
595 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000597 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 = Context.getTagDeclType(
599 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
600 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000601 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
603 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
604 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000605 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000606 MD->getThisType(Context),
607 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
609 }
610 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000611 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
612 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000614 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 }
616
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000617 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000618 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
619 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000620 }
621
622 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
623 // anonymous struct/union.
624 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000625 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000626 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
627 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
628 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
629 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000630 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
631 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
632
633 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
634 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
635 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
636 ResultQuals.removeConst();
637
638 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
639 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
640
641 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
642 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
643
644 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
645 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
646 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
647
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000648 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000649 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000650 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000651 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
652 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000653 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000654 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000655 }
656
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000657 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000658}
659
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000660/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000661/// possibly a list of template arguments.
662///
663/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
664/// DecomposeTemplateName.
665///
666/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
667/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
668/// some way.
669static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
670 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
671 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000672 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000673 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
674 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
675 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
676 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
677
678 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
679 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
680 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
681 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
682 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
683
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000684 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000685 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
686 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
688 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000689 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000690 TemplateArgs = 0;
691 }
692}
693
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
695/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
696/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000697static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000698 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
699 return false;
700
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000701 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
702 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
703 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
704 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
705 if (!BaseRT) return false;
706
707 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000708 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000709 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
710 return false;
711 }
712
713 return true;
714}
715
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
717/// the prospective base classes.
718static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
719 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
720 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000721 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000722 return false;
723
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000724 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000725 if (!RD) return false;
726 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
727
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000728 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
729 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
730 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
731 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
732 if (!BaseRT) return false;
733
734 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
736 return false;
737 }
738
739 return true;
740}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000741
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000742enum IMAKind {
743 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
744 IMA_Static,
745
746 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
747 IMA_Mixed,
748
749 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
750 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
751 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
754 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
755 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
756
757 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
758 IMA_Instance,
759
760 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
761 IMA_Unresolved,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
764 /// context is not an instance method.
765 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
766
767 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
768 /// non-class context.
769 IMA_AnonymousMember,
770
771 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
772 /// context is not an instance method.
773 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
774
775 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
776 /// class.
777 IMA_Error_Unrelated
778};
779
780/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
781/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
782/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
783/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
784/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
785/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
786static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
787 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000788 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000789
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000790 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000791 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000792 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
793 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794
795 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
796 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
797
798 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
799 bool hasNonInstance = false;
800 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
801 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000802 NamedDecl *D = *I;
803 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000804 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
805
806 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
807 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
808 // that's a special case.
809 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
810 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
811 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
812 }
813 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
814 }
815 else
816 hasNonInstance = true;
817 }
818
819 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
820 // member reference.
821 if (Classes.empty())
822 return IMA_Static;
823
824 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
825 // an implicit member reference.
826 if (isStaticContext)
827 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
828
829 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
830 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
831 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
832 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000833 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000834 Classes))
835 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
836
837 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
838}
839
840/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
841static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
842 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
843 const LookupResult &R) {
844 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
845 SourceRange Range(Loc);
846 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
847
848 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
849 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
850 if (MD->isStatic()) {
851 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
852 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
853 << Range << R.getLookupName();
854 return;
855 }
856 }
857
858 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
859 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
860 return;
861 }
862
863 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000864}
865
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
867///
868/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000869bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
870 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
872
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000873 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000874 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
876 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000879 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
880 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
883 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
884 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
885 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000886 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000887 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000888 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
889 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
890
891 if (!R.empty()) {
892 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
893 R.suppressDiagnostics();
894
895 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
896 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
897 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
898 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
899
900 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
901 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
902 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000903 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000904 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
905 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000906 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000907 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000908 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000909 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
910 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
911 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
912 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
913 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
914 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
915 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
916 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
917 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
918 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
919 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
920 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
921 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
922 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000924 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
925 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
926 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000927 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000928 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000930 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000939
940 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000941 }
942 }
943
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000944 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000946 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000947 if (!R.empty()) {
948 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
949 if (SS.isEmpty())
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
951 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
952 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
955 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
956 << SS.getRange()
957 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
958 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
959 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
960 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
961 << ND->getDeclName();
962
963 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
964 return false;
965 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000966
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000967 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
969 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
970 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
971 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
972 // to recover well anyway.
973 if (SS.isEmpty())
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
975 else
976 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
977 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
978 << SS.getRange();
979
980 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
981 return true;
982 }
983 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000984 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000988 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000990 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
991 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 return true;
993 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000994 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000995 }
996
997 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
998 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
999 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1000 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1001 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1002 << SS.getRange();
1003 return true;
1004 }
1005
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001006 // Give up, we can't recover.
1007 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1008 return true;
1009}
1010
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001011static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001012 IdentifierInfo *II,
1013 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001014 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1015 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1016 if (!IDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1019 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1020 return 0;
1021 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1022 if (!property)
1023 return 0;
1024 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1025 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1026 return 0;
1027 return property;
1028}
1029
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001030static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001031 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001032 IdentifierInfo *II,
1033 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1034 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001035 bool LookForIvars;
1036 if (Lookup.empty())
1037 LookForIvars = true;
1038 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1039 LookForIvars = false;
1040 else
1041 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1042 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1043 if (!LookForIvars)
1044 return 0;
1045
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001046 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1047 if (!IDecl)
1048 return 0;
1049 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001050 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1051 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001052 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1053 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1054 if (!property)
1055 return 0;
1056 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1057 DynamicImplSeen =
1058 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1059 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001060 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1061 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001062 NameLoc,
1063 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1064 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1065 (Expr *)0, true);
1066 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1067 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1068 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1069 return Ivar;
1070 }
1071 return 0;
1072}
1073
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001074ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001075 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1076 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1077 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1078 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1080 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1081
1082 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001083 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001084
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001085 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086
1087 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001088 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001090 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001091
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001092 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001093 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001094 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001095
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1097 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001098 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1099 // (note: handled after lookup)
1100 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1101 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1102 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001103 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1104 // names a dependent type.
1105 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1106 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001107 bool DependentID = false;
1108 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1109 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1110 DependentID = true;
1111 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1112 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1113 if (DC) {
1114 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1115 return ExprError();
1116 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1117 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1118 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1119 } else {
1120 DependentID = true;
1121 }
1122 }
1123
1124 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001125 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 TemplateArgs);
1127 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001128 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001129 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001130 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001132 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1133 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1134 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1135 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1136 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001137 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1138 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1139 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001141 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001142 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001143
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1145 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001146 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001147 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (E.isInvalid())
1149 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001150
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1152 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001153 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1154 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001155 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001156 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1157 isAddressOfOperand);
1158 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001159 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1160 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001161 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001162 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001163
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001164 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1165 return ExprError();
1166
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001167 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1168 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001170
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001172 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1174 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1175 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1176 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1177 }
1178
1179 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1180 // call, diagnose the problem.
1181 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001182 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001183 return ExprError();
1184
1185 assert(!R.empty() &&
1186 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187
1188 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1189 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001190 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001191 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1192 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001193 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001194 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1195 return move(E);
1196 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001197 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001198 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001199
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1201 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1202
1203 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001204 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001205 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1206 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001207 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1208 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1209 if (Property) {
1210 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1211 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001212 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001213 }
1214 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001216 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1217 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1218 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1219 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1220 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1221 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001222 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001224
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001225 QualType T = Func->getType();
1226 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001227 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001228 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1229 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001231 }
1232 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001233
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001234 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001235 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1236 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1237 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1238 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1239 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1240 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1241 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1242 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001243 //
1244 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1245 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1246 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1247 // non-static member function:
1248 //
1249 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1250 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1251 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1252 // member function call.
1253 //
1254 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1255 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1256 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1257 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001258 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001259 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1260 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1261 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1262 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1263 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1264 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1265 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001266 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1267 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001268 else
1269 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1270
1271 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001272 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001273 }
1274
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 if (TemplateArgs)
1276 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001277
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001278 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1279}
1280
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001281/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001282ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001283Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1284 LookupResult &R,
1285 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1286 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1287 case IMA_Instance:
1288 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1289
1290 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1291 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1292 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1293 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1294
1295 case IMA_Mixed:
1296 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1297 case IMA_Unresolved:
1298 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1299
1300 case IMA_Static:
1301 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1302 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1303 if (TemplateArgs)
1304 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1305 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1306
1307 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1308 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1309 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1310 return ExprError();
1311 }
1312
1313 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1314 return ExprError();
1315}
1316
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001317/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1318/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1319/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1320/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001321ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001322Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001323 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001325 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001326 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001327
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001328 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001329 return ExprError();
1330
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001331 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1333
1334 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1335 return ExprError();
1336
1337 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001338 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1339 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001340 return ExprError();
1341 }
1342
1343 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1344}
1345
1346/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1347/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1348/// additional lookup.
1349///
1350/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1351/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1352///
1353/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001354ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001355Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001356 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001358 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001359
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001360 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1361 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1362 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1363 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1364 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1365
1366 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1367 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1368 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001369 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370
1371 bool LookForIvars;
1372 if (Lookup.empty())
1373 LookForIvars = true;
1374 else if (IsClassMethod)
1375 LookForIvars = false;
1376 else
1377 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1378 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001379 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001381 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001382 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1383 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1384 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1385 if (IsClassMethod)
1386 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1387 << IV->getDeclName());
1388
1389 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1390 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1391 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1392 return ExprError();
1393
1394 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1395 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1396 return ExprError();
1397
1398 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1399 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1400 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1401 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1402
1403 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1404 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1405 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1406 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001407 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001408 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001409 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001410 SelfName, false, false);
1411 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1412 return Owned(new (Context)
1413 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1414 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1415 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001416 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001417 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001419 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1420 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1421 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1422 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1424 }
1425 }
1426
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001427 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1428 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1429 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1430 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1431 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1432 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1433 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1434 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1435 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1436 }
1437 }
1438 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001439 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1440 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001441}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001442
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001443/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1444///
1445/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1446///
1447/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1448/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1449/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1450/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1451///
1452/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1453/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1454/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1455/// the class declaring the member.
1456///
1457/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1458/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1459/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001460bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1462 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464 NamedDecl *Member) {
1465 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1466 if (!RD)
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 QualType DestRecordType;
1470 QualType DestType;
1471 QualType FromRecordType;
1472 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1473 bool PointerConversions = false;
1474 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1475 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001477 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1478 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1479 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1480 PointerConversions = true;
1481 } else {
1482 DestType = DestRecordType;
1483 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001484 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1486 if (Method->isStatic())
1487 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001488
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1490 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1493 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1494 PointerConversions = true;
1495 } else {
1496 FromRecordType = FromType;
1497 DestType = DestRecordType;
1498 }
1499 } else {
1500 // No conversion necessary.
1501 return false;
1502 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1505 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1508 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1509 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001511 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1512 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1513
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001514 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001515
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001518 // class name.
1519 //
1520 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1521 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1522 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1523 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1524 //
1525 // class Base { public: int x; };
1526 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1527 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1528 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1529 //
1530 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1531 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1532 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1533 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1536 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1537 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1538
1539 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1540
1541 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1542 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1543 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1544 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001545 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001547 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 return true;
1549
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001552 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1553 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554
1555 FromType = QType;
1556 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1557
1558 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1559 // we're done.
1560 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1561 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 }
1563 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001564
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001565 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001566
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001567 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1568 // down to the using declaration's type.
1569 //
1570 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1571 // class ever has member declarations.
1572 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1573 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1574 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1575 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1576
1577 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1578 // conversion is non-trivial.
1579 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1580 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001581 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001582 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001583 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001585
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001586 QualType UType = URecordType;
1587 if (PointerConversions)
1588 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001589 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001590 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001591 FromType = UType;
1592 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1593 }
1594
1595 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1596 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1597 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001598 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001599
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001600 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001601 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1602 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001603 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001604 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001605
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001606 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001607 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001608 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001609}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001610
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001611/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001612static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001613 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001614 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001615 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1616 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1618 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1619 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001620 if (SS.isSet()) {
1621 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1622 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001626 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1627 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001628}
1629
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001630/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1631/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1632/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1633/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001634ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001635Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1636 LookupResult &R,
1637 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1638 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1640
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001641 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001642
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001643 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1644 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001645 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001648 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001650
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001651 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1652 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001653 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1654 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001655 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1656 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001657 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1658 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1659 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1660 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001661 }
1662
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001663 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001664 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1665 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001666 SS,
1667 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1668 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669}
1670
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 const LookupResult &R,
1673 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1675 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1676 return false;
1677
1678 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 return false;
1681
1682 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684 return false;
1685
1686 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1687 // normal lookup:
1688 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1689 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a declaration of a class member
1693 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1694 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001695 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696 return false;
1697
1698 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1699 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1700 // using-declaration
1701 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1702 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1703 // turn off ADL anyway).
1704 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1705 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1706 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1707 return false;
1708
1709 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1710 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1711 // template
1712 // And also for builtin functions.
1713 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1714 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1715
1716 // But also builtin functions.
1717 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1718 return false;
1719 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1720 return false;
1721 }
1722
1723 return true;
1724}
1725
1726
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1728/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1729/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1730/// will in fact be used.
1731static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1732 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1733 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1734 return true;
1735 }
1736
1737 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1738 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1739 return true;
1740 }
1741
1742 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1743 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1744 return true;
1745 }
1746
1747 return false;
1748}
1749
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001750ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001751Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001752 LookupResult &R,
1753 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001754 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1755 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001756 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001757 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1758 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759
1760 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1761 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1762 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001763 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1764 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 return ExprError();
1766
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001767 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1768 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1769 // we've picked a target.
1770 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1771
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001772 bool Dependent
1773 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001775 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001776 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001777 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001778 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1779 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001780
1781 return Owned(ULE);
1782}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001783
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784
1785/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001786ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001787Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001788 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1789 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001790 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001791 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1792 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001793
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001794 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001795 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1796 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001797
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001798 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1799 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1800 // a template argument list.
1801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1802 << Template << SS.getRange();
1803 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1804 return ExprError();
1805 }
1806
1807 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1808 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1809 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001811 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001812 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001813 return ExprError();
1814 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001816 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1817 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1818 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1819 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001821 return ExprError();
1822
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001823 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1824 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001825 return ExprError();
1826
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001827 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1828 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1829 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1830 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001831 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001832 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1833 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1834 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001835 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001836 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001837 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1840 return ExprError();
1841 }
1842
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001843 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001844 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1845 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1846 return ExprError();
1847 }
1848
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001849 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001850 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001851 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001852 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001853 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001854 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1855 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001856 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001858 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001859 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001860 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1861 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001862 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1864 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1865 Expr *E = new (Context)
1866 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1867 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001868
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001869 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001870 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001871 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001872 SourceLocation(),
1873 Owned(E));
1874 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001875 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001876 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1877 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1878 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001879 }
1880 }
1881 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001882 }
1883 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1884 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001885
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001886 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1887 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001888}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001889
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001890ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001891 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001892 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001894 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001895 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001896 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1897 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1898 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001899 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001900
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001901 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1902 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001904 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001905 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1906 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001907 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001908 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001909 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001910 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001912 QualType ResTy;
1913 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1914 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1915 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001916 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001918 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001919 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001920 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1921 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001922 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001923}
1924
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001925ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001926 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001927 bool Invalid = false;
1928 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1929 if (Invalid)
1930 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001932 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1933 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001934 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001936
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 QualType Ty;
1938 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1939 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1940 else if (Literal.isWide())
1941 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001942 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1943 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001944 else
1945 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001946
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001947 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1948 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001949 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001950}
1951
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001954 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1955 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001956 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001957 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001958 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001959 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001960 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001961
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001962 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001963 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1964 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001965 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001967 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001968 bool Invalid = false;
1969 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1970 if (Invalid)
1971 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001973 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001974 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001975 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 return ExprError();
1977
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001978 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001980 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001981 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001982 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001983 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001984 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001985 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001986 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001987 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001988
1989 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1990
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001991 using llvm::APFloat;
1992 APFloat Val(Format);
1993
1994 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001995
1996 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1997 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1998 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1999 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002001 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002002 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002003 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002004 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2005 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002006 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002007 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2008 }
2009
2010 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2011 << Ty
2012 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2013 }
2014
2015 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002016 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002017
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002018 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002020 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002021 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002023 // long long is a C99 feature.
2024 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002025 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2027
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002028 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2032 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002034 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2035 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002036 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002037 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002038 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2039 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002041 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2042 // be an unsigned int.
2043 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2044
2045 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002047 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2048 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002050
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2052 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2053 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2054 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002055 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002056 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002059 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002062 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002066 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2067 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2068 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2069 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002070 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002071 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002075 }
2076
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002077 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002079 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002080
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002081 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2082 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2083 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2084 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 }
2090 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002091
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002092 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2093 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002094 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002095 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002096 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002098 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002099
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2101 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002102 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002103 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002104 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002105
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002106 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2107 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002108 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002109 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002110
2111 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002112}
2113
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002114ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002115 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002116 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002117 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002118}
2119
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002120/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002121/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002122bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002123 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2124 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2125 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002126 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2127 return false;
2128
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002129 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2130 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2131 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2132 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2133 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2134 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2135
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002136 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002137 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 if (isSizeof)
2140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002145 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2147 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002148 return false;
2149 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002150
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002152 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2153 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002154 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002156 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002157 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002159 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2160 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002161 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002163 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2164 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2165 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2166 return true;
2167 }
2168
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002169 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002170}
2171
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002172bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2173 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2174 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002175
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002176 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002177 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2178 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002179
2180 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2181 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2182 return false;
2183
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002184 if (E->getBitField()) {
2185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2186 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002187 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002188
2189 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2190 // bit-field.
2191 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002192 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002193 return false;
2194
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002195 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2196}
2197
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002198/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002199ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002201 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002202 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002203 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002204 return ExprError();
2205
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002206 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002207
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002208 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2209 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2210 return ExprError();
2211
2212 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002213 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002214 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2215 R.getEnd()));
2216}
2217
2218/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2219/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002220ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002221Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002222 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2223 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2224 bool isInvalid = false;
2225 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2226 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2227 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2228 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002229 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002230 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2231 isInvalid = true;
2232 } else {
2233 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2234 }
2235
2236 if (isInvalid)
2237 return ExprError();
2238
2239 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2240 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2241 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2242 R.getEnd()));
2243}
2244
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002245/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2246/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2247/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002248ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002249Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2250 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002251 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002252 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002253
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002254 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002256 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002257 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002258 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002259
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002260 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002261 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002262 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2263
2264 if (Result.isInvalid())
2265 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2266
2267 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002268}
2269
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002270QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002271 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2272 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002273
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002274 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002275 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002276 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002277
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002278 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2279 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2280 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002281
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002282 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002283 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2284 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002285 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002286}
2287
2288
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002289
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002290ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002291Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002292 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002293 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002294 switch (Kind) {
2295 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002296 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2297 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002298 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002299
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002300 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002301}
2302
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002303ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002304Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2305 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002306 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002307 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002308 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2309 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002310
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002311 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002313 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002314 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002315 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2316 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2317 }
2318
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002320 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002321 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2322 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2323 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002324 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002325 }
2326
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002327 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002328}
2329
2330
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002331ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002332Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2333 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2334 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2335 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002336
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002337 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002338 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2339 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2340 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002341
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002342 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002343
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002344 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002345 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002346 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002347 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002348 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2349 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002350 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2351 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2353 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002354 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002355 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2356 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002357 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002358 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002359 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002360 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2361 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002362 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002363 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002364 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002365 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2366 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2367 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002369 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002370 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2371 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2372 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2373 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002374 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002375 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002376 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002377
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002378 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2379 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002380 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2381 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002382 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002383 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2384 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2385 // force the promotion here.
2386 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2387 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002388 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002389 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002390 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2391
2392 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2393 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002394 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002395 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2396 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2397 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2398 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002399 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002400 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002401 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2402
2403 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2404 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002405 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002406 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002407 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2408 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002409 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002410 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002411 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002412 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2413 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002414
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002415 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002416 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2417 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002418 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2419
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002420 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2422 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002423 // incomplete types are not object types.
2424 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2425 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2426 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2427 return ExprError();
2428 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002429
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002430 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002432 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2433 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002434 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002435
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002436 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002437 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002438 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2439 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2440 return ExprError();
2441 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002443 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002444 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002445}
2446
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002447QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002448CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002449 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002450 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002451 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2452 // see FIXME there.
2453 //
2454 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2455 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002456 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002457
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002458 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002459 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002460
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002461 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002462 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2463 // to be selected.
2464 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002465
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2467 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002468 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002469
2470 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2471 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002472 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002473 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2474 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002475 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002476 do
2477 compStr++;
2478 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002479 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002480 do
2481 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002482 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002483 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002484
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002485 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002486 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2487 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002488 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002489 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002490 return QualType();
2491 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002492
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002493 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2494 // operates on.
2495 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002496 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002497
2498 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002499 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002500
2501 while (*compStr) {
2502 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2503 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2504 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2505 return QualType();
2506 }
2507 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002508 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002509
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002510 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002511 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002512 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002513 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002514 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002515 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002516 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002517 if (HexSwizzle)
2518 CompSize--;
2519
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 if (CompSize == 1)
2521 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002522
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002523 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002524 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002525 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2526 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2527 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2528 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002529 }
2530 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002531}
2532
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002533static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002534 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002535 const Selector &Sel,
2536 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002538 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002539 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002540 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002541 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002542
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002543 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2544 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002545 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002546 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002547 return D;
2548 }
2549 return 0;
2550}
2551
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002552static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002553 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002554 const Selector &Sel,
2555 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002556 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2557 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002558 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002559 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002560 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002561 GDecl = PD;
2562 break;
2563 }
2564 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002565 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 GDecl = OMD;
2567 break;
2568 }
2569 }
2570 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002571 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002572 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2573 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002574 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002575 if (GDecl)
2576 return GDecl;
2577 }
2578 }
2579 return GDecl;
2580}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002581
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002582ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002583Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002585 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2586 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002587 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002588 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2590 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2591 //
2592 // T* t;
2593 // t.f;
2594 //
2595 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2596 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2597 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2598 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002599 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002600 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2601 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002602 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002603 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002604 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002605 return ExprError();
2606 }
2607 }
2608
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002609 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2610 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002611 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002612
2613 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2614 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002615 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002617 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002618 SS.getRange(),
2619 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002620 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621}
2622
2623/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2624/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2625/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2626static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2627 Expr *BaseExpr,
2628 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002629 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002631 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2632 // diagnostics.
2633 if (!BaseExpr)
2634 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002635
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002636 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2637 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638}
2639
2640// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2641// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2642// type. The restriction here is:
2643//
2644// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2645// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2646// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2647//
2648// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2649// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2650// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2651// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2652bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2653 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002654 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002655 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2657 if (!BaseRT) {
2658 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2659 // dependent.
2660 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2661 return false;
2662 }
2663 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002664
2665 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2667 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002668 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002670
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002671 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002672 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2673 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2674 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002676 if (!DC->isRecord())
2677 continue;
2678
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002680 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681
2682 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2683 return false;
2684 }
2685
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002687 return true;
2688}
2689
2690static bool
2691LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2692 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002693 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2694 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002695 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2696 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002697 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 << BaseRange))
2699 return true;
2700
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002701 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2702 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2703 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2704
2705 bool MOUS;
2706 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2707 return false;
2708 }
2709
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002710 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2711 if (SS.isSet()) {
2712 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2713 // nested-name-specifier.
2714 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2715
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002716 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002717 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2718 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2719 return true;
2720 }
2721
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002723
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2725 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2726 << DC << SS.getRange();
2727 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 }
2729 }
2730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2732 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002734 if (!R.empty())
2735 return false;
2736
2737 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2738 // for typos.
2739 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002740 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002741 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002742 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2743 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2744 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002745 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2746 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002747 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2748 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2749 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002750 return false;
2751 } else {
2752 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002753 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002754 }
2755
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 return false;
2757}
2758
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002759ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002760Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002761 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002762 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002764 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002766 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2767 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002768 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2770 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002771 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002773 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 // Implicit member accesses.
2776 if (!Base) {
2777 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2778 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2779 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2780 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002781 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782 return ExprError();
2783
2784 // Explicit member accesses.
2785 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002786 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002787 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002788 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002789
2790 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2791 Owned(Base);
2792 return ExprError();
2793 }
2794
2795 if (Result.get())
2796 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002797
2798 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2799 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800 }
2801
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002802 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002803 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2804 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805}
2806
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002807ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002808Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002809 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2810 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002811 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002813 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2814 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002815 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816 if (IsArrow) {
2817 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2818 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2819 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002820 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002822 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002823 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2824 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2825 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826
2827 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002828 return ExprError();
2829
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830 if (R.empty()) {
2831 // Rederive where we looked up.
2832 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2833 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2834 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002835
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002837 << MemberName << DC
2838 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002839 return ExprError();
2840 }
2841
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002842 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2843 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2844 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2845 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2846 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2847 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2848 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2849 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2850 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2851 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002852 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002853 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002854 return ExprError();
2855
2856 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2857 // result.
2858 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002859 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002860 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002861 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002862 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002864 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2865 // pick a member.
2866 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2867
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2869 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2870 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002871 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2872 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002874 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002875 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876
2877 return Owned(MemExpr);
2878 }
2879
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002880 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002881 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002882 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2883
2884 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2885
2886 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2887 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2888 // error cases.
2889 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2890 return ExprError();
2891
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002892 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2893 if (!BaseExpr) {
2894 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002895 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002896 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002897
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002898 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2899 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2900 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2901 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002902 }
2903
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2905 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2906 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2907 // explicitly qualified.
2908 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2909 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2910 }
2911
2912 // Check the use of this member.
2913 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2914 Owned(BaseExpr);
2915 return ExprError();
2916 }
2917
2918 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2919 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2920 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002921 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2922 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2924 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2925
2926 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2927 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2928 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2929 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2930 else {
2931 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2932 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2933 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2934
2935 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2936 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2937
2938 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2939 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2940 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2941 }
2942
2943 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002944 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945 return ExprError();
2946 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002947 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2948 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949 }
2950
2951 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2952 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2953 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002954 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2956 }
2957
2958 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2959 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2960 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002961 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002962 MemberFn->getType()));
2963 }
2964
2965 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2966 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2967 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002968 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2969 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002970 }
2971
2972 Owned(BaseExpr);
2973
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002974 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002975 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002976 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002977 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2978 else
2979 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2980 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002982 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2983 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002984 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002985 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002986}
2987
2988/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2989/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2990/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2991/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2992/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2993/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2994/// an ordinary member expression.
2995///
2996/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2997/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002998ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002999Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003000 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003001 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003002 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003003 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003004
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003005 // Perform default conversions.
3006 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003007
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003008 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003009 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3010
3011 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3012 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003013
3014 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003015 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003016 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3017 // call, and continue on.
3018 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3019 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3020 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3021 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3022 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003023 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3024 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003025 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3026 ->isRecordType()))) {
3027 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3028 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3029 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003030 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003031
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003032 ExprResult NewBase
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003033 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003034 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003035 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003036 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003038
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003039 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3040 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3041 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3042 }
3043 }
3044 }
3045
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003046 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3047 // use that.
3048 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003049 if (IsArrow) {
3050 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3051 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3052 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003053 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003054 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003055 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3056 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003057 }
3058 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003059 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3060 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3061 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3062 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003063 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003064 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003065 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003067 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3068 // use that.
3069 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3070 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3071 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3072 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3073 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003074 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003075 }
3076 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003077
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003078 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003079
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003081 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003082 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3083 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3084 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3085 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3086 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3087 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3088 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3089 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3090 // Check the use of this method.
3091 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3092 return ExprError();
3093 }
3094 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3095 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3096 Selector SetterSel =
3097 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3098 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3099 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3100 if (!Setter) {
3101 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3102 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003103 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003104 }
3105 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3106 if (!Setter)
3107 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003108
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003109 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3110 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003111
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 if (Getter || Setter) {
3113 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003114
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003115 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003116 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 else
3118 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3119 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3120 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003121 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003122 PType,
3123 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3124 }
3125 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3126 << MemberName << BaseType);
3127 }
3128 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003129
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3131 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3132 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003133 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003134 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003135
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003136 if (IsArrow) {
3137 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003138 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003139 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3140 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003141 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3142 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3143 // struct MyRecord foo;
3144 // foo->bar
3145 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3146 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3147 // by now.
3148 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3149 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003150 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003151 IsArrow = false;
3152 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003153 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3154 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3155 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003156 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003157 } else {
3158 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3159 // type *foo;
3160 // foo.bar
3161 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3162 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3163 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3164 // the appropriate pointer type
3165 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3166 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3167 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3168 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3169 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003170 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003171 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3172 IsArrow = true;
3173 }
3174 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003175 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003176
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003177 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003178 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003179 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003180 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003181 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003182 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003183 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003184
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003185 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3186 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003187 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003188 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003189 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003190 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3191 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3192 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3193 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3195
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003196 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003197 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003198
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003199 if (!IV) {
3200 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3201 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3202 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003203 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003204 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003205 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003206 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3207 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003208 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3209 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003210 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003211 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003212 } else {
3213 Res.clear();
3214 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003215 }
3216 }
3217
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 if (IV) {
3219 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3220 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3221 // error cases.
3222 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003224
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3226 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3227 return ExprError();
3228 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3229 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3230 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3231 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3232 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3233 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3234 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3235 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3236 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3237 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3238 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3239 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003240 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003241 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003242 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3243 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003244 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003245 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3246 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003247
3248 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3249 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003251 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003253 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3254 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003255 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003256 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003257 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258
3259 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3260 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003261 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003262 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003263 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003264 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003265 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003266 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003267 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003268 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3270 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003271 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003274 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003275 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003276 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3277 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3278 // Check the use of this declaration
3279 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3280 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003282 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3283 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3284 }
3285 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3286 // Check the use of this method.
3287 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3288 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003289
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003290 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003291 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003292 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3293 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003294 }
3295 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003296
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003297 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003298 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003299 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003300
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003301 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3302 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003303 if (!IsArrow)
3304 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3305 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003306 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003308 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003309 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003310 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3311 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003312 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003313 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003314 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003315
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003316 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003317 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003318 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003319 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3320 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003321 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003322 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003323 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003324 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003325
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003326 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3327 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3328
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003329 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003330}
3331
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003332/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3333/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3334/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3335/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3336/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3337///
3338/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3339/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3340/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3341/// only be called
3342/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3343/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3344/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003345ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003346 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3347 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003348 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003349 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003350 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003351 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3352 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3353 return ExprError();
3354
3355 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3356
3357 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003358 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3360 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003361 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003363 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003364 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3365
3366 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3367 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3368 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3369
3370 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003371 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003372 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3373 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003374
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003375 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3376 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003377 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003378 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3379 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003380 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003381 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003382 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003383 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3384 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003385
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003386 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3387 Owned(Base);
3388 return ExprError();
3389 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003390
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003391 if (Result.get()) {
3392 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3393 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3394 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3395 // call now.
3396 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3397 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003398 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003399
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003400 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003401 }
3402
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003403 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003404 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3405 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003406 }
3407
3408 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003409}
3410
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003411ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003412 FunctionDecl *FD,
3413 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3414 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3415 Diag (CallLoc,
3416 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3417 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003418 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003419 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3420 } else {
3421 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3422 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3423
3424 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003425 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3426 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003427
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003428 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3429 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3430 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3431 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003432
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003433 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003434 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003435 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003436
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003437 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3438 InitializedEntity Entity
3439 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3440 InitializationKind Kind
3441 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3442 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3443 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3444
3445 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003446 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003447 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003448 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003449 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003450
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003451 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003452 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003453 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003455
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003456 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3457 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3458 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003459 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3460 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003461 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3462 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003463 }
3464
3465 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003466 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003467}
3468
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003469/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3470/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3471/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3472/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3473/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3474/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003475bool
3476Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003477 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003478 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3480 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003481 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3483 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003484 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003485
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3487 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3488 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3489 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3490 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003491 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003492 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003493 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003494 }
3495
3496 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3497 // them.
3498 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3499 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3500 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3501 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003502 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003503 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003504 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3505 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3506 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003507 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003508 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003509 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003510 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003511 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003512 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003513 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3514 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3515 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3516 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3517 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003518 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003519 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003520 if (Invalid)
3521 return true;
3522 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3523 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3524 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003525
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003526 return false;
3527}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003528
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003529bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3530 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3531 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3532 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3533 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3534 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003535 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003536 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3537 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3538 bool Invalid = false;
3539 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3540 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3541 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3542 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003543 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003544 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003546
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003548 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3549 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003550
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003551 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3552 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003553 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003554 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003555 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003556
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003557 // Pass the argument
3558 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3559 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3560 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003561
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003562
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003563 InitializedEntity Entity =
3564 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3565 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003566 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003567 SourceLocation(),
3568 Owned(Arg));
3569 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3570 return true;
3571
3572 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003573 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003574 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003575
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003576 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003577 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003578 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3579 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003581 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003582 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003583 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003584 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003587 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003588 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003589 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003590 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003591 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003592 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003593 }
3594 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003595 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596}
3597
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003598/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003599/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3600/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003601ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003602Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003603 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003604 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003605 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003606
3607 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003608 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003609 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3610 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003611
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003612 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003613
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003614 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003615 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3616 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3617 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3618 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3619 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003620 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003621 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3622 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003624 NumArgs = 0;
3625 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003626
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003627 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3628 RParenLoc));
3629 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003630
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003631 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003632 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003633 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3634 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003635 bool Dependent = false;
3636 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3637 Dependent = true;
3638 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3639 Dependent = true;
3640
3641 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003642 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003643 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3644
3645 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3646 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3647 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3648 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3649
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003650 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3651
3652 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3653 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3654 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3655 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3656 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3657 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3658 // method template.
3659 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003660 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3661 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003662 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003663
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003664 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3665 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003666 }
3667
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003668 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003669 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003670 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003671 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003672 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3673 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003674 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003675
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003676 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003677 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003678 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3679 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003680 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3681 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003682 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003683
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003684 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3685 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3686 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3687 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003688
3689 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3690 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003691 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003692 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003693
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003694 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003695 RParenLoc))
3696 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003697
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003698 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003699 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003700 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003701 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3702 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003703 }
3704 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003705 }
3706
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003707 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003708 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003709 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003710
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003711 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003712 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3713 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003714 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003715 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003716 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003717
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003718 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3719 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3720 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3721
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003722 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3723}
3724
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003725/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3726/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003727/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3728/// block-pointer type.
3729///
3730/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003731ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003732Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3733 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3734 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3735 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3736 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3737
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003738 // Promote the function operand.
3739 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3740
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003741 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3742 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003743 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3744 Args, NumArgs,
3745 Context.BoolTy,
3746 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003747
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003748 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3749 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3750 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3751 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003752 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003753 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003754 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3755 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003756 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003757 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003758 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003759 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003760 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003761 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003762 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3763 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3764
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003765 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003766 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003767 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003768 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003769 return ExprError();
3770
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003771 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003772 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003773
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003774 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003775 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003776 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003777 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003778 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003779 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003780
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003781 if (FDecl) {
3782 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3783 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3784 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003785 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003786 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003787 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003788 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3789 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3790 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3791 }
3792 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003793 }
3794
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003795 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003796 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3797 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3798 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003799 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3800 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003801 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3802 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003803 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003804 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003805 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003806 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003807
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003808 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3809 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003810 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3811 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003812
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003813 // Check for sentinels
3814 if (NDecl)
3815 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003816
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003817 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003818 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003819 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003820 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003821
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003822 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003823 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003824 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003825 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003826 return ExprError();
3827 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003828
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003829 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003830}
3831
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003832ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003833Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003834 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003835 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003836 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003837 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003838
3839 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3840 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3841 if (!TInfo)
3842 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3843
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003844 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003845}
3846
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003847ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003848Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003849 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003850 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003851
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003852 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003853 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003854 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3855 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003856 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3857 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003858 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003859 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003860 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003861 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003862
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003863 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003864 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003865 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003866 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003867 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003868 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003869 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003870 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003871 &literalType);
3872 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003873 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003874 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003875
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003876 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003877 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003878 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003879 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003880 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003881
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003882 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003883 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003884}
3885
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003886ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003887Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003888 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3889 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003890 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003891
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003892 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003893 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003894
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003895 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3896 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003897 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003898 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003899}
3900
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003901static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003902 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003903 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003904 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003905
3906 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3907 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003908 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003909 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3910 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003911 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003912 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003913 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003914
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003915 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3916 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003917 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003918 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003919 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003921 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003922 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003923
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003924 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3925 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003928 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003929 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003931 // FIXME: Assert here.
3932 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003933 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003934}
3935
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003936/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003937bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003938 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003939 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003940 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003941 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003942 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3943 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003944
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003945 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003946
3947 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3948 // type needs to be scalar.
3949 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3950 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003951 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003952 return false;
3953 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003955 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3956 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3957 return true;
3958
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003959 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003960 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003961 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3962 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003963 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003964 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3965 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003966 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003967 return false;
3968 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003969
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003970 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003971 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003972 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003973 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003974 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003975 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003976 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003977 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003978 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3979 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3980 break;
3981 }
3982 }
3983 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3984 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3985 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003986 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003987 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003988 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003989
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003990 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3991 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3992 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003994
3995 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003996 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003997 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3998 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003999 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004001
4002 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004003 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004004
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004005 if (castType->isVectorType())
4006 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4007 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4008 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4009
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004010 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4011 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004012
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004013 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004014 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004015 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004016 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004017 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4018 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4019 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4020 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004021 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004022 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4023 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4024 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004025 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004026
4027 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004028
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004029 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004030 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4031
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004032 return false;
4033}
4034
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004035bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004036 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004037 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004038
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004039 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004040 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004041 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004042 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004043 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004044 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004045 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004046 } else
4047 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004048 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004049 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004050
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004051 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004052 return false;
4053}
4054
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004055bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004056 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004057 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004058
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004059 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004060
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004061 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4062 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004063 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4064 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4065 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4066 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004067 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004068 return false;
4069 }
4070
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004071 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004072 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4073 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004074 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4075 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4076 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4077 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004078
4079 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4080 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4081 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004082
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004083 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004084 return false;
4085}
4086
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004087ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004088Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004089 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4090 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004091 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004092
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004093 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4094 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4095 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004096 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004097
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004098 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4099 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004100 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004101 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004102
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004103 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004104}
4105
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004106ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004107Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004108 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004109 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004110 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004111 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004112 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004113 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004114
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004115 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004116 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004117 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4118 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004119}
4120
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004121/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4122/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004123ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004124Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004125 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4126 if (!E)
4127 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004128
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004129 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004130
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004131 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004132 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4133 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004134
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004135 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4136
4137 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004138}
4139
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004140ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004142 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004143 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004144 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004145 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004146 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004148 // Check for an altivec literal,
4149 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004150 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4151 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4152 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4153 return ExprError();
4154 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004155 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4156 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4157 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4158 }
4159 else
4160 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4161 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004162
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004163 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4164 // then handle it as such.
4165 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004166 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4167 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4168 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4169
4170 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4171 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004172 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4173 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004174 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4175 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004176 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004177 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004179 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004180 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004181 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4182 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004183 }
4184}
4185
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004186ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004187 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004188 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004189 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004190 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4191 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004192 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4193 Expr *expr;
4194 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4195 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4196 else
4197 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004198 return Owned(expr);
4199}
4200
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004201/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4202/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004203/// C99 6.5.15
4204QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4205 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004206 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4207 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4208 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4209
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004210 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4211 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4212 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4213 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4214 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4215 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004216
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004217 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004218 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4219 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4220 << CondTy;
4221 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004222 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004223
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004224 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004225 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4226 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004227
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004228 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4229 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004230 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4231 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4232 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004233 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004234
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004235 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4236 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004237 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4238 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004239 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004240 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004241 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004242 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004243 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004244 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004245
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004246 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004247 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004248 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4249 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4250 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4251 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4252 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4253 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4254 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004255 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4256 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004257 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004258 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004259 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4260 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004261 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004262 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004263 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004264 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004265 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004266 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004267 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004268 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004269 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004270 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004271 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004272
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004273 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4274 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4275 QuestionLoc);
4276 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4277 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004278
4279
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004280 // Handle block pointer types.
4281 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4282 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4283 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4284 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004285 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4286 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004287 return destType;
4288 }
4289 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004290 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004291 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004292 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004293 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4294 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4295 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004296 return LHSTy;
4297 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004298 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004299 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4300 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004301
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004302 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4303 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004304 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004305 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004306 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4307 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4308 // to get a consistent AST.
4309 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004310 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4311 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004312 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004313 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004314 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004315 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4316 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004317 return LHSTy;
4318 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004319
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004320 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4321 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4322 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004323 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4324 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004325
4326 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4327 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4328 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004329 QualType destPointee
4330 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004331 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004332 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004333 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004334 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004335 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004336 return destType;
4337 }
4338 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004339 QualType destPointee
4340 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004341 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004342 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004343 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004344 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004345 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004346 return destType;
4347 }
4348
4349 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4350 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4351 return LHSTy;
4352 }
4353 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4354 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4355 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4356 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4357 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4358 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4359 // to get a consistent AST.
4360 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004361 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4362 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004363 return incompatTy;
4364 }
4365 // The pointer types are compatible.
4366 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4367 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4368 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4369 // type.
4370 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4371 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004372 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4373 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004374 return LHSTy;
4375 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004376
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004377 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4378 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4379 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4380 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004381 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004382 return RHSTy;
4383 }
4384 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4385 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4386 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004388 return LHSTy;
4389 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004390
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004391 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004392 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4393 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004394 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004395}
4396
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004397/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4398/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4399QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4400 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4401 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4402 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004403
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004404 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4405 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4406 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4407 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4408 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004409 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004410 return LHSTy;
4411 }
4412 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4413 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004414 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004415 return RHSTy;
4416 }
4417 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4418 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4419 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004420 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004421 return LHSTy;
4422 }
4423 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4424 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004425 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004426 return RHSTy;
4427 }
4428 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4429 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4430 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004431 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004432 return LHSTy;
4433 }
4434 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4435 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004436 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004437 return RHSTy;
4438 }
4439 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4440 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004441
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004442 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4443 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4444 return LHSTy;
4445 }
4446 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4447 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4448 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004449
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004450 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4451 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4452 // type. This allows
4453 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4454 // where B is a subclass of A.
4455 //
4456 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4457 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4458 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4459 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004460
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004461 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4462 // It could return the composite type.
4463 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4464 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4465 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4466 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4467 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4468 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4469 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4470 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4471 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4472 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4473 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4474 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4475 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4476 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004477 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004478 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4479 ;
4480 else {
4481 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4482 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4483 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4484 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004485 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4486 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004487 return incompatTy;
4488 }
4489 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004490 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4491 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004492 return compositeType;
4493 }
4494 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4495 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4496 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4497 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4498 QualType destPointee
4499 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4500 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4501 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004502 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004503 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004504 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004505 return destType;
4506 }
4507 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4508 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4509 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4510 QualType destPointee
4511 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4512 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4513 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004514 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004515 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004516 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004517 return destType;
4518 }
4519 return QualType();
4520}
4521
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004522/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004523/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004524ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004525 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004526 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4527 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004528 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4529 // was the condition.
4530 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4531 if (isLHSNull)
4532 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004533
4534 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004535 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004536 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004537 return ExprError();
4538
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004539 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004540 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004541 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004542}
4543
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004544// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004545// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004546// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4547// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4548// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004549Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004550Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004551 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004553 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4554 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4555 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4556 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4557 return Compatible;
4558 }
4559
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004560 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004561 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4562 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004563
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004564 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004565 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4566 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004567
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004568 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004569
4570 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4571 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4572 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004573 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004574 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004575 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004576
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004577 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4578 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004579 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004580 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004581 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004582 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004583
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004584 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004585 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4586 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004587 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004588
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004589 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004590 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004591 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004592
4593 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004594 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4595 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004596 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004597 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004598 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004599 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4600 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4601 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4602 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4603 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4604 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004605 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004607 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004608 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004609
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004610 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004611 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004612 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004613 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004614
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004615 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4616 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4617 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4618 // warning can be disabled.
4619 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4620 return ConvTy;
4621 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4622 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004623
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004624 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4625 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4626 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4627 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4628 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4629 do {
4630 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4631 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004632
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004633 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4634 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4635 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004636
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004637 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004638 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004639 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004640
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004641 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004642 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004643 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004644 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004645}
4646
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004647/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4648/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4649/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4650// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004651Sema::AssignConvertType
4652Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004653 QualType rhsType) {
4654 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004655
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004656 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004657 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4658 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004659
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004660 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4661 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4662 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004663
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004664 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004665
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004666 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004667 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004668 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004669
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004670 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4671 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4672 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4673 }
4674 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004675 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004676 return ConvTy;
4677}
4678
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004679/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4680/// for assignment compatibility.
4681Sema::AssignConvertType
4682Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004683 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4684 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004685 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4686 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004687 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004688 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004689 }
4690 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4691 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004692 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4693 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004694 return IncompatiblePointer;
4695 return Compatible;
4696 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004697 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004698 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004699 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004700 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4701 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4702 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4703 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4704 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4705 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004706
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004707 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4708 return Compatible;
4709 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4710 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004711 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004712}
4713
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4715/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004716/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4717///
4718/// int a, *pint;
4719/// short *pshort;
4720/// struct foo *pfoo;
4721///
4722/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4723/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4724/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4725/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4726///
4727/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004728/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004729///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004730Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004731Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004732 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4733 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004734 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4735 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004736
4737 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004738 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004739
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004740 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4741 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4742 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4743 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4744 return Compatible;
4745 }
4746
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004747 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4748 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4749 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4750 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4751 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4752 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4753 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004754 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004755 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004756 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004757 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004758 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004759 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4760 // to the same ExtVector type.
4761 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4762 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4763 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004764 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004765 return Compatible;
4766 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004767
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004768 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004769 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4770 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4771 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4772 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4773 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4774 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004775 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004776
4777 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4778 // vector type and vice versa
4779 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4780 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004781 }
4782 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004783 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004784
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004785 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4786 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004787 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004788
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004789 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004790 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004791 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004792
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004793 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004794 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004795
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004796 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004797 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004798 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4799 return Compatible;
4800 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004801 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004802 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4803 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004804 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004805
4806 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004807 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004808 return Compatible;
4809 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004810 return Incompatible;
4811 }
4812
4813 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4814 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004815 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004816
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004817 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004818 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004819 return Compatible;
4820
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004821 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4822 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004823
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004824 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004825 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004826 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004827 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004828 return Incompatible;
4829 }
4830
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004831 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4832 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4833 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004834
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004835 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004836 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004837 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4838 return Compatible;
4839 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004840 }
4841 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004842 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004843 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004844 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004845 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4846 return Compatible;
4847 }
4848 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4849 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4850 return Compatible;
4851 return Incompatible;
4852 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004853 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004854 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004855 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4856 return Compatible;
4857
4858 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004859 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004860
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004861 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004862 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004863
4864 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004865 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004866 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004867 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004868 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004869 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4870 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4871 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4872 return Compatible;
4873
4874 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4875 return PointerToInt;
4876
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004877 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004878 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004879 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4880 return Compatible;
4881 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004882 }
4883 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004884 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004885 return Compatible;
4886 return Incompatible;
4887 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004888
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004889 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004890 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004891 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004892 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004893 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004894}
4895
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004896/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4897/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004898static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004899 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4900 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4901 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004902 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004903 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004904 SourceLocation());
4905 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4906 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4907
4908 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4909 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004910 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004911 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004912 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004913}
4914
4915Sema::AssignConvertType
4916Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4917 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4918
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004919 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004920 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4921 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004922 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004923 return Incompatible;
4924
4925 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4926 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4927 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4928 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004929 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4930 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004931 it != itend; ++it) {
4932 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4933 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4934 // 1) void pointer
4935 // 2) null pointer constant
4936 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004937 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004938 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004939 InitField = *it;
4940 break;
4941 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004942
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004943 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004944 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004945 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004946 InitField = *it;
4947 break;
4948 }
4949 }
4950
4951 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4952 == Compatible) {
4953 InitField = *it;
4954 break;
4955 }
4956 }
4957
4958 if (!InitField)
4959 return Incompatible;
4960
4961 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4962 return Compatible;
4963}
4964
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004965Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004966Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004967 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4968 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4969 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4970 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4971 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004972 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004973 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004974 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004975 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004976 }
4977
4978 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4979 // structures.
4980 }
4981
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004982 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4983 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004984 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4985 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004986 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004987 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004988 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004989 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004990 return Compatible;
4991 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004992
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004993 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004994 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004995 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004996 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004997 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004998 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004999 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005000 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005001
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005002 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5003 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005004
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005005 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5006 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005007 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5008 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5009 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5010 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005011 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005012 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005013 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005014 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005015}
5016
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005017QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005018 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005019 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005020 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005021 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005022}
5023
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005024QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005025 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005026 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005027 QualType lhsType =
5028 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5029 QualType rhsType =
5030 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005031
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005032 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005033 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005034 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005035
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005036 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5037 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005038 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005039 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005040 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005041 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005042 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005043 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005044 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005045 return lhsType;
5046 }
5047
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005048 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005049 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005050 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5051 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5052 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5053 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5054 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5055 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005056 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005057 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005058 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005059 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005060
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005061 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5062 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5063 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005064 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005065 return rhsType;
5066 }
5067
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005068 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5069 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5070 bool swapped = false;
5071 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5072 swapped = true;
5073 std::swap(rex, lex);
5074 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5075 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005076
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005077 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005078 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005079 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005080 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005081 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005082 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005083 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5084 return lhsType;
5085 }
5086 }
5087 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5088 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5089 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005090 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005091 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5092 return lhsType;
5093 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005094 }
5095 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005096
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005097 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005098 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005099 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005100 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005101 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005102}
5103
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005104QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5105 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005106 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005107 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005108
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005109 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005110
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005111 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5112 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5113 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005114
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005115 // Check for division by zero.
5116 if (isDiv &&
5117 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005118 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005119 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005120
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005121 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005122}
5123
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005124QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005125 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005126 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005127 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5128 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005129 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5130 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5131 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005132
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005133 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005134
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005135 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5136 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005137
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005138 // Check for remainder by zero.
5139 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005140 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5141 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005142
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005143 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005144}
5145
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005146QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005147 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005148 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5149 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5150 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5151 return compType;
5152 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005153
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005154 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005155
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005156 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005157 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5158 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5159 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005160 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005161 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005162
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005163 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5164 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005165 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005166 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5167
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005168 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005169
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005170 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005171 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005172
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005173 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5174 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005175 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5176 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005177 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005178 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005179 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005180
5181 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5182 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5183 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005184 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005185 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5186 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5187 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5188 return QualType();
5189 }
5190
5191 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5192 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5193 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005194 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005195 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005196 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005197 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005198 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5199 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005200 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5201 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005202 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005203 return QualType();
5204 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005205 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005206 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005207 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5208 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5209 return QualType();
5210 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005212 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005213 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5214 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5215 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5216 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5217 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005218 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005219 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5220 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005221 return PExp->getType();
5222 }
5223 }
5224
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005225 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005226}
5227
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005228// C99 6.5.6
5229QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005230 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5231 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5232 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5233 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5234 return compType;
5235 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005236
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005238
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005240
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005241 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005242 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5243 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005244 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005245 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005246 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005247
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005248 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005249 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005250 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005251
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005252 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005253
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005254 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5255 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5256 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5257 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5258 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5259 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5260 return QualType();
5261 }
5262
5263 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5264 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5265 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5266 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5267 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005268 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005269 return QualType();
5270 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005271
5272 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5273 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5274 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005275 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005276 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005277 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005278 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005279 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005280
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005281 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005282 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005283 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5284 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5285 return QualType();
5286 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005287
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005288 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005289 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5290 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5291 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5292 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5293 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5294 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005295 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005296 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5297
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005298 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005299 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005300 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005301
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005302 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005303 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005304 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005305
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005306 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5307 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5308 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5309 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5310 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5311 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5312 return QualType();
5313 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005314
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005315 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5316 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5317 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5318 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005319 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005320 return QualType();
5321 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005322
5323 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5324 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5325 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5326 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5327 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005328 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5329 << rex->getSourceRange()
5330 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005331 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005332
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005333 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5334 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5335 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5336 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5337 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5338 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5339 return QualType();
5340 }
5341 } else {
5342 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5343 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5344 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5345 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5346 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5347 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5348 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5349 return QualType();
5350 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005351 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005352
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005353 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5354 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5355 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5356 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5357 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005358 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005359 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005360
5361 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005362 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5363 }
5364 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005365
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005366 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005367}
5368
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005369// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005370QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005371 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005372 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005373 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5374 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005375 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005376
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005377 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5378 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5379 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5380
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005381 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5382 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005383 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5384 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5385 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5386 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5387 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005388 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005389 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005390 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005391
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005392 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005393
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005394 // Sanity-check shift operands
5395 llvm::APSInt Right;
5396 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005397 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5398 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005399 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005400 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5401 else {
5402 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5403 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5404 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5405 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5406 }
5407 }
5408
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005409 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005410 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005411}
5412
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005413static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5414 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5415 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5416 return true;
5417 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5418 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5419 }
5420 return false;
5421}
5422
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005423// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005424QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005425 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005426 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005427
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005428 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005429 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005430 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005431
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005432 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5433 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005434
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005435 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5436 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005437 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5438 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5439 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005440 //
5441 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5442 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5443 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5444 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5445 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5446 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005447 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5448 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005449 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005450 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005451 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005452 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005453 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5454 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005455 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5456 || Opc == BO_LE
5457 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005458 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5459 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5460 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5461 // what is it always going to eval to?
5462 char always_evals_to;
5463 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005464 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005465 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5466 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005467 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005468 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5469 break;
5470 default:
5471 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5472 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5473 break;
5474 }
5475 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5476 << 1 // array
5477 << always_evals_to);
5478 }
5479 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005480 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005481
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005482 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5483 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5484 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5485 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005486
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005487 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5488 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005489 Expr *literalString = 0;
5490 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005491 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005492 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005493 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005494 literalString = lex;
5495 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005496 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5497 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005498 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005499 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005500 literalString = rex;
5501 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5502 }
5503
5504 if (literalString) {
5505 std::string resultComparison;
5506 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005507 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5508 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5509 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5510 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5511 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5512 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005513 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5514 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005515
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005516 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5517 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5518 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005519 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005520 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005521 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005522
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005523 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5524 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5525 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5526 else {
5527 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5528 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5529 }
5530
5531 lType = lex->getType();
5532 rType = rex->getType();
5533
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005534 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005535 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005536
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005537 if (isRelational) {
5538 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005539 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005540 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005541 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005542 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005543 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005544
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005545 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005546 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005547 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005548
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005549 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005550 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005551 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005552 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005553
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005554 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5555 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005556 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005557 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005558 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005559 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005560 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005561
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005562 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005563 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5564 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005565 if (!isRelational &&
5566 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5567 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5568 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005569 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5570 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005571 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5572 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005573 Diag(Loc,
5574 isSFINAEContext()?
5575 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5576 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005577 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005578
5579 if (isSFINAEContext())
5580 return QualType();
5581
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005582 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005583 return ResultTy;
5584 }
5585 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005586 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5587 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5588 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5589 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5590 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5591 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005592 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005593 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005594 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005595 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005596 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005597 if (T.isNull()) {
5598 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5599 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5600 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005601 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005602 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005603 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005604 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005605 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005606 }
5607
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005608 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5609 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005610 return ResultTy;
5611 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005612 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5613 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5614 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5615 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5616 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5617 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5618 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5619 }
5620 } else if (!isRelational &&
5621 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5622 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5623 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5624 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5625 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5626 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5627 }
5628 } else {
5629 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005630 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005631 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005632 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005633 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005634 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005635 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005636 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005637
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005638 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005639 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005640 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005641 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005642 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5643 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005644 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5645 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005646 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5647 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005648 return ResultTy;
5649 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005650 if (LHSIsNull &&
5651 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5652 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005653 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5654 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005655 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5656 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005657 return ResultTy;
5658 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005659
5660 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005661 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005662 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5663 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005664 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5665 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5666 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5667 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5668 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5669 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5670 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5671 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005672 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005673 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005674 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005675 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005676 if (T.isNull()) {
5677 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005678 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005679 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005680 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005681 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005682 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005683 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005684 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005685 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005686
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005687 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5688 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005689 return ResultTy;
5690 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005691
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005692 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005693 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5694 return ResultTy;
5695 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005696
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005697 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005698 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005699 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5700 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005701
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005702 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005703 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005704 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005705 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005706 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005707 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005708 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005709 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005710 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005711 if (!isRelational
5712 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5713 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005714 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005715 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005716 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005717 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005718 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5719 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5720 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005721 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005722 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005723 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005724 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005725
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005726 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005727 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005728 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5729 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005730 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005731 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005732 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005733 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005734
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005735 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5736 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005737 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005738 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005739 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005740 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005741 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005742 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005743 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005744 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005745 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5746 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005747 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005748 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005749 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005750 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005751 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5752 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005753 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005754 bool isError = false;
5755 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5756 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5757 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005758 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005759 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005760 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005761 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5762 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5763 isError = true;
5764 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005765 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005766
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005767 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005768 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005769 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005770 if (isError)
5771 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005772 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005773
5774 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005775 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005776 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005777 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005778 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005779 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005780
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005781 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005782 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5783 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005784 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005785 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005786 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005787 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5788 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005789 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005790 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005791 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005792 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005793}
5794
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005795/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005796/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005797/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5798/// types.
5799QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005800 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801 bool isRelational) {
5802 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5803 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005804 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005805 if (vType.isNull())
5806 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005807
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005808 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5809 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005810
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005811 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5812 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5813 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005814 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005815 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5816 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5817 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005818 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5819 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5820 << 0 // self-
5821 << 2 // "a constant"
5822 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005823 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005824
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005825 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005826 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5827 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005828 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005829 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005830
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005831 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5832 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5833 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005834 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005835 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005837 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005838 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005839 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005840 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005841 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005842 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5843
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005844 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005845 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005846 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5847}
5848
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005849inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005850 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005851 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5852 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5853 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5854 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5855
5856 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5857 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005858
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005859 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005860
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005861 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005862 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005863 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005864}
5865
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005866inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005867 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5868
5869 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5870 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5871 // is a constant.
5872 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005873 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005874 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005875 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5876 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5877 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5878 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5879 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5880 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5881 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5882 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5883 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005884 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5885 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005886 }
5887 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005888
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005889 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5890 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5891 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005892
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005893 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5894 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005895
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005896 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005897 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005898
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005899 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5900 // non-overloadable operands.
5901
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005902 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5903 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005904 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5905 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5906 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005907 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005908
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005909 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5910 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5911 // The result is a bool.
5912 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005913}
5914
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005915/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5916/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5917/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5918///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005919static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005920 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5921 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5922 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5923 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005925 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5926 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5927 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5928 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005929 }
5930 }
5931 return false;
5932}
5933
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005934/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5935/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5936static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005937 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005938 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005939 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005940 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5941 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005942 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5943 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005944
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005945 unsigned Diag = 0;
5946 bool NeedType = false;
5947 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005948 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005949 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005950 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5951 NeedType = true;
5952 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005954 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5955 NeedType = true;
5956 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005957 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005958 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5959 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005960 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5961 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005962 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005963 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5964 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005965 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5966 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005967 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5968 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005969 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005970 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005971 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005972 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005973 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5974 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005975 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005976 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5977 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005978 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5979 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5980 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005981 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5982 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5983 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005984 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5985 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5986 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005987 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005988
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005989 SourceRange Assign;
5990 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5991 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005992 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005993 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005994 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005995 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005996 return true;
5997}
5998
5999
6000
6001// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006002QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6003 SourceLocation Loc,
6004 QualType CompoundType) {
6005 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6006 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006007 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006008
6009 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6010 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006011 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006012 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006013 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006014 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006015 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6016 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6017 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6018 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6019 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6020 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6021 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6022 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6023 }
6024 }
6025
6026 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006027 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6028 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6029 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006030 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006031 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006032 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006033 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006034
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006035 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6036 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6037 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006038 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006039 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6040 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6041 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006042 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6043 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006044 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006045 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006046 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6047 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6048 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006049 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6050 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006051 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006052 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006053 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006054 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006055 }
6056 } else {
6057 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006058 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006059 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006060
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006061 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006062 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006063 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006064
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006065
6066 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6067 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6068 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6069 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6070 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6071 // check.
6072 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006073 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006074 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6075 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6076 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6077 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6078 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6079 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6080 }
6081
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006082 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6083 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006084 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006085 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6086 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006087 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006088 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006089 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006090}
6091
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006092// C99 6.5.17
6093QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006094 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6095
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006096 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006097 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6098 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6099 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006100
6101 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6102 // incomplete in C++).
6103
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006104 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006105}
6106
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006107/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6108/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006109QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006110 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006111 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6112 return Context.DependentTy;
6113
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006114 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6115 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006116
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006117 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6118 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6119 if (!isInc) {
6120 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6121 return QualType();
6122 }
6123 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6125 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006126 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006127 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6128 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006129
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006131 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006132 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6134 << Op->getSourceRange();
6135 return QualType();
6136 }
6137
6138 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006140 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006141 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6142 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6143 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6144 return QualType();
6145 }
6146
6147 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006148 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006149 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006150 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006151 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006152 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006153 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006154 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006155 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006156 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6157 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6158 return QualType();
6159 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006160 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006161 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6162 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006163 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006164 } else {
6165 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006166 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006167 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006168 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006169 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006170 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006171 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006172 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006173 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6174 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6175 // operand.
6176 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6177 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006178}
6179
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006180/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006181/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006182/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6183/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6184/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6185/// - &(x) => x
6186/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6187/// - &s.xx => s
6188/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6189/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6190/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6191/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006192static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006193 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006194 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006195 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006196 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006197 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6198 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6199 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006200 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006201 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006202 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006203 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006204 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006205 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6206 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006207 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6208 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6209 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6210 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6211 }
6212 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006213 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006214 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6215 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006216
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006217 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006218 case UO_Real:
6219 case UO_Imag:
6220 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006221 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6222 default:
6223 return 0;
6224 }
6225 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006226 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006227 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006228 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006229 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6230 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006231 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006232 default:
6233 return 0;
6234 }
6235}
6236
6237/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006238/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006239/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006240/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006241/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006242/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006243/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006244QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6245 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006246 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006247 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6248 return Context.OverloadTy;
6249
6250 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6251 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006252
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006253 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6254 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6255 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006256 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006257 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6258 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6259 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6260 }
6261 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6262 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6263 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006264 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006265 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006266
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006267 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006268 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6269 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6270 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6271 if (isSFINAEContext())
6272 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006273 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006274 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006275 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6276 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6277 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6278
6279 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6280 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6281 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6282 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6283 return QualType();
6284 }
6285 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6286 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6287
6288 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6289 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6290 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6291 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6292
6293 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6294 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6295 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6296 << op->getSourceRange();
6297 }
6298
6299 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6300 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6301 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006302 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006303 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006304 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006305 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6307 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006308 return QualType();
6309 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006310 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006311 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6312 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6313 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006314 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006315 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006316 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006317 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006318 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006319 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006320 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6321 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6322 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6323 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6324 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006325 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6326 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006327 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6328 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006329 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006330 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006331 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6332 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006333 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6334 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006335 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006336 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006337 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6338 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006339 return QualType();
6340 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006341 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006342 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006343 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006344 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006345 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6346 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006347 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006348 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006349 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6350 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006351 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006352 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6353 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6354 return QualType();
6355 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006356
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006357 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6358 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006359 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006360 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006361 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006362 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006363 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006364
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006365 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6366 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6367 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6368 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6369 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6370 }
6371
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006372 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006373 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6374 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006375 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006376}
6377
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006378/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006379QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006380 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6381 return Context.DependentTy;
6382
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006383 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006384 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6385 QualType Result;
6386
6387 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6388 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6389 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6390 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6391 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6392 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6393 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6394 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6395 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006396
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006397 if (Result.isNull()) {
6398 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6399 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6400 return QualType();
6401 }
6402
6403 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006404}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006405
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006406static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006407 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006408 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006409 switch (Kind) {
6410 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006411 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6412 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6413 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6414 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6415 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6416 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6417 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6418 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6419 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6420 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6421 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6422 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6423 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6424 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6425 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6426 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6427 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6428 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6429 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6430 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6431 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6432 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6433 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6434 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6435 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6436 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6437 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6438 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6439 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6440 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6441 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6442 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006443 }
6444 return Opc;
6445}
6446
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006447static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006448 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006449 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006450 switch (Kind) {
6451 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006452 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6453 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6454 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6455 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6456 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6457 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6458 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6459 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6460 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6461 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6462 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006463 }
6464 return Opc;
6465}
6466
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006467/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6468/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6469/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006470ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006471 unsigned Op,
6472 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006473 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006474 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006475 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6476 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6477 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006478
6479 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006480 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006481 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6482 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006483 case BO_PtrMemD:
6484 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006485 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006486 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006487 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006488 case BO_Mul:
6489 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006490 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006491 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006492 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006493 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006494 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6495 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006496 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006497 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6498 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006499 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006500 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6501 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006502 case BO_Shl:
6503 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006504 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6505 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006506 case BO_LE:
6507 case BO_LT:
6508 case BO_GE:
6509 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006510 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006511 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006512 case BO_EQ:
6513 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006514 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006515 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006516 case BO_And:
6517 case BO_Xor:
6518 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006519 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6520 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006521 case BO_LAnd:
6522 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006523 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006524 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 case BO_MulAssign:
6526 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006527 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006528 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006529 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6530 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6531 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006532 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006533 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006534 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6535 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6536 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6537 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006538 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006539 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006540 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6541 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6542 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006543 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006544 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006545 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6546 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6547 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006548 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006549 case BO_ShlAssign:
6550 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006551 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6552 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6553 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6554 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006555 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006556 case BO_AndAssign:
6557 case BO_XorAssign:
6558 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006559 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6560 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6561 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6562 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006563 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006565 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6566 break;
6567 }
6568 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006569 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006570 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006571 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006572 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6573 << ResultTy;
6574 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006575 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006576 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6577 else
6578 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006579 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6580 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006581}
6582
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006583/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6584/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006585static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6586 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006587 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6588 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6589 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006590 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006591 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6592
6593 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6594 return;
6595
6596 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6597 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6598 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006599 return;
6600 }
6601
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006602 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6603 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006604 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006605
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006606 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006607 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006608
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006609 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6610 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6611 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6612 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006613 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006614 return;
6615 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006616
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006617 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006618 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6619 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006620}
6621
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006622/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6623/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6624/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6625/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006626static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006627 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006628 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6629 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6630 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6631 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006632 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006633 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006634 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6635
6636 // Subs are not binary operators.
6637 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6638 return;
6639
6640 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6641 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006642 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6643 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006644 return;
6645
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006646 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006647 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006648 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006649 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6650 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006651 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006652 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006653 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6654 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6655 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6656 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006657 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006658 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006659 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006660 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6661 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006662 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006663 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006664 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6665 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6666 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6667 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006668}
6669
6670/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6671/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6672/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006673static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006674 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006675 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006676 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6677}
6678
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006679// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006680ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006681 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6682 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6683 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006684 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6685 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006686
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006687 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6688 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6689
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006690 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6691}
6692
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006693ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006694 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6695 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006696 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006697 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006698 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6699 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6700 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6701 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6702 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006703 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006704 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006705 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6706 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6707 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006708
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006709 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6710 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006711 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006712 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006713
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006714 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006715 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006716}
6717
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006718ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006719 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006720 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006721 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006722
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006723 QualType resultType;
6724 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006725 case UO_PreInc:
6726 case UO_PreDec:
6727 case UO_PostInc:
6728 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006729 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006730 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6731 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6732 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6733 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006734 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006735 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006736 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006737 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006738 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006739 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006740 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006741 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006742 case UO_Plus:
6743 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006744 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6745 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006746 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6747 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006748 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6749 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006750 break;
6751 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6752 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6753 break;
6754 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006755 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006756 resultType->isPointerType())
6757 break;
6758
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006759 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6760 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006761 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006762 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6763 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006764 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6765 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006766 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6767 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6768 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006769 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006770 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006771 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006772 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6773 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006774 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006775 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006776 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006777 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006778 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006779 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6780 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006781 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006782 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6783 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006784 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006785 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6786 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006787 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006788 case UO_Real:
6789 case UO_Imag:
6790 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006791 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006792 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006793 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006794 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006795 }
6796 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006797 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006798
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006799 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006800}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006801
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006802ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006803 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6804 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006805 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006806 Opc != UO_Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006807 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6808 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6809 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6810 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006811 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006812 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006813 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6814 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6815 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006816
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006817 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006818 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006819
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006820 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006821}
6822
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006823// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006824ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006825 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6826 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006827}
6828
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006829/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006830ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006831 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6832 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006833 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006834 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006835
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006836 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6837 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006838 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006839 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006840
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006841 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006842 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6843 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006844}
6845
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006846ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006847Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006848 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006849 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6850 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6851
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006852 bool isFileScope
6853 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006854 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006855 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006856
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006857 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6858 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6859 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006860
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006861 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6862 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6863 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006864
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006865 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6866 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6867 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6868 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6869 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006870
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006871 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006872 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006873 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006874
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006875 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6876 // expressions are not lvalues.
6877
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006878 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006879}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006880
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006881ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006882 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006883 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6884 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006885 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6886 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006887 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006888 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006889
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006890 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6891 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6892 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006893 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6895 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6896
6897 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6898 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6899 if (!Dependent
6900 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6901 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6902 << TypeRange))
6903 return ExprError();
6904
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006905 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6906 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006907 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6908 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006909 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006910 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6911 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006912
6913 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6914 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6915 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6916 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6917 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6918 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6919 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6920 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6921 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6922 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6923 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6924 if(!AT)
6925 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6926 << CurrentType);
6927 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6928 } else
6929 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6930
6931 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6932 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6933 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6934 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6935 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6936 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6937 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6938 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6939
6940 // Record this array index.
6941 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6942 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6943 continue;
6944 }
6945
6946 // Offset of a field.
6947 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6948 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6949 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6950 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6951 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6952 continue;
6953 }
6954
6955 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6956 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6957 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6958 return ExprError();
6959
6960 // Look for the designated field.
6961 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6962 if (!RC)
6963 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6964 << CurrentType);
6965 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6966
6967 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6968 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6969 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6970 // (clause 9).
6971 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6972 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6973 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6974 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6975 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6976 << CurrentType))
6977 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6978 }
6979
6980 // Look for the field.
6981 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6982 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6983 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6984 if (!MemberDecl)
6985 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6986 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6987 OC.LocEnd));
6988
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006989 // C99 7.17p3:
6990 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6991 //
6992 // We diagnose this as an error.
6993 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6994 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6995 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6996 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6997 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6998 return ExprError();
6999 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007000
7001 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7002 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7003 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7004 do {
7005 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7006 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7007 }
7008
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007009 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7010 // the base class indirections.
7011 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7012 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007013 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007014 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7015 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7016 B != BEnd; ++B)
7017 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7018 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007019
7020 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007021 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7022 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7023 unsigned n = Path.size();
7024 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7025 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7026 } else {
7027 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7028 }
7029 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7030 }
7031
7032 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7033 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7034 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7035}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007036
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007037ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007038 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7039 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007040 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007041 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7042 unsigned NumComponents,
7043 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7044
7045 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7046 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7047 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7048 return ExprError();
7049
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007050 if (!ArgTInfo)
7051 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7052
7053 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7054 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007055}
7056
7057
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007058ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007059 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007060 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007061 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7062 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7063 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7064 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007065
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007066 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007067
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007068 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7069}
7070
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007071ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007072Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7073 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7074 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7075 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007076 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7077 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7078 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7079 return ExprError();
7080 }
7081
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007082 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007083 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007084}
7085
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007086
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007087ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007088 Expr *CondExpr,
7089 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007090 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007091 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7092
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007093 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007094 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007095 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007096 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007097 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007098 } else {
7099 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7100 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7101 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7102 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007103 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7104 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7105 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007106
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007107 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7108 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007109 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7110 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007111 }
7112
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007113 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007114 resType, RPLoc,
7115 resType->isDependentType(),
7116 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007117}
7118
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007119//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7120// Clang Extensions.
7121//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7122
7123/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007124void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007125 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7126 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7127 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007128 if (BlockScope)
7129 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7130 else
7131 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007132}
7133
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007134void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007135 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007136 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007137
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007138 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007140 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007141
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007142 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007143 QualType RetTy;
7144 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007145 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007146 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007147 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007148 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7149 } else {
7150 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007151 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007152 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007153
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007154 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007155
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007156 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7157 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7158 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007159 return;
7160 }
7161
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007162 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7163 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7164 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7165 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7166 return;
7167 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007168
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007169 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007170 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7171 // ^ * { ... }
7172 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007173 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7174 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007175
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007176 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007177 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007178 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7179 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7180 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7181 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007182 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7183 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7184 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7185 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7186 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007187 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007188 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007189
7190 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7191 // ^ fntype { ... }
7192 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7193 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7194 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7195 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7196 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7197 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7198 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007199 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007200 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007201 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007202
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007203 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7204 if (!Params.empty())
7205 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007206
7207 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007208 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007209
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007210 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007211 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7212 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7213 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7214 }
7215
7216 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7217 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007218 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007219 return;
7220
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007221 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7222 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7223
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007224 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007225 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7226 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7227
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007228 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007229 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7230 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7231 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7232
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007233 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007234 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007235 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007236}
7237
7238/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7239/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7240void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007241 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007242 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007243 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007244 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007245}
7246
7247/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7248/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007249ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007250 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007251 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7252 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7253 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007254
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007255 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007256
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007257 PopDeclContext();
7258
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007259 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007260 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7261 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007262
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007263 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007264 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007265
7266 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7267 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7268 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7269
7270 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7271 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7272
7273 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7274 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7275 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7276 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7277
7278 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7279 // preserve its sugar structure.
7280 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7281 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7282 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7283
7284 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7285 } else {
7286 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7287 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7288 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7289 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7290 FPT->isVariadic(),
7291 /*quals*/ 0,
7292 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7293 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7294 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7295 FPT->exception_begin(),
7296 Ext);
7297 }
7298
7299 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7300 } else {
7301 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7302 false, false, 0, 0,
7303 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7304 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007305
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007306 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007307 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7308 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007309 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007310
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007311 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007312 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007313 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007314
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007315 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007316
7317 bool Good = true;
7318 // Check goto/label use.
7319 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7320 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7321 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7322
7323 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7324 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7325 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7326 continue;
7327
7328 // Emit error.
7329 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7330 Good = false;
7331 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007332 if (!Good) {
7333 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007334 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007335 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007336
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007337 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7338 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7339
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007340 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007341 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7342 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007343 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007344
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007345 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007346 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007347}
7348
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007349ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007350 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007351 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007352 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7353 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007354 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007355}
7356
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007357ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007358 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007359 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007360 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007361
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007362 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007363
7364 // Get the va_list type
7365 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007366 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7367 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7368 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7369 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007370 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007371 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7372 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7373 } else {
7374 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7375 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007376 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007377 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007378 return ExprError();
7379 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007380
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007381 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7382 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007383 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7384 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007385 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007386 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007387
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007388 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007389 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007390
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007391 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7392 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007393}
7394
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007395ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007396 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7397 // pointers on the target.
7398 QualType Ty;
7399 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7400 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7401 else
7402 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7403
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007404 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007405}
7406
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007407static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007408 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007409 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7410 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007411
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007412 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7413 if (!PT)
7414 return;
7415
7416 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7417 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7418 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7419 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7420 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7421 return;
7422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007424 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7425 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7426 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7427 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007428
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007429 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007430}
7431
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007432bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7433 SourceLocation Loc,
7434 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007435 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7436 bool *Complained) {
7437 if (Complained)
7438 *Complained = false;
7439
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007440 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7441 bool isInvalid = false;
7442 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007443 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007444
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007445 switch (ConvTy) {
7446 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7447 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007448 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007449 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7450 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007451 case IntToPointer:
7452 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7453 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007454 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007455 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007456 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7457 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007458 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7459 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7460 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007461 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7462 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7463 break;
7464 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007465 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7466 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7467 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7468 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7469 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7470 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7471 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7472 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7473 // C++ semantics.
7474 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7475 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7476 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007477 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7478 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007479 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007480 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007481 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007482 case IntToBlockPointer:
7483 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7484 break;
7485 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007486 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007487 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007488 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007489 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007490 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7491 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7492 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007493 case IncompatibleVectors:
7494 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7495 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007496 case Incompatible:
7497 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7498 isInvalid = true;
7499 break;
7500 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007501
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007502 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7503 switch (Action) {
7504 case AA_Assigning:
7505 case AA_Initializing:
7506 // The destination type comes first.
7507 FirstType = DstType;
7508 SecondType = SrcType;
7509 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007510
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007511 case AA_Returning:
7512 case AA_Passing:
7513 case AA_Converting:
7514 case AA_Sending:
7515 case AA_Casting:
7516 // The source type comes first.
7517 FirstType = SrcType;
7518 SecondType = DstType;
7519 break;
7520 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007521
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007522 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007523 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007524 if (Complained)
7525 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007526 return isInvalid;
7527}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007529bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007530 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7531 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7532 if (Result)
7533 *Result = ICEResult;
7534 return false;
7535 }
7536
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007537 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7538
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007539 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007540 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7541 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7542
7543 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7544 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7545 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7546 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7547 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7548 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7549 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007550
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007551 return true;
7552 }
7553
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007554 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7555 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007556
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007557 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7558 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7559 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007560
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007561 if (Result)
7562 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7563 return false;
7564}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007565
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007566void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007567Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007568 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7569 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007570}
7571
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007572void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007573Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7574 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7575 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7576 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007577
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007578 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7579 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7580 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7581 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7582 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007584 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7585 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7586 I != IEnd; ++I)
7587 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7588 }
7589
7590 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7591 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7592 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7593 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7594 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7595 I != IEnd; ++I)
7596 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7597 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007598 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007599
7600 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7601 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7602 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7603 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007604 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007605 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7606 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7607 ExprTemporaries.end());
7608
7609 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7610 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007611}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007612
7613/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7614///
7615/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7616/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7617/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7618/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7619///
7620/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7621///
7622/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7623void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7624 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007625
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007626 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007627 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007628
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007629 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7630 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7631 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7632 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007633 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007634 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007635 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007636 return;
7637 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007638
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007639 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7640 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007641
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007642 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7643 // an instantiation.
7644 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7645 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007646
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007647 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007648 case Unevaluated:
7649 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7650 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007651
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007652 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7653 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7654 // "used"; handle this below.
7655 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007656
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007657 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7658 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7659 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7660 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007661 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007662 return;
7663 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007664
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007665 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007666 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007667 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007668 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007669 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7670 return;
7671 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7672 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007673 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007674 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007675 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007676 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7677 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007678
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007679 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007680 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007681 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007682 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007683 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7684 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007685 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7686 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7687 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007688 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007689 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007690 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7691 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007692 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007693 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007694 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007695 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007696 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007697 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7698 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7699 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7700 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7701 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007703 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007704 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007705 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007706 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7707 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7708 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007709 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007710 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007711 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7712 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007713
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007714 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7715 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7716 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7717 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7718 Loc));
7719 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007720 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007721 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007722 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7723 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7724 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007725 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007726 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7727 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007728
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007729 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007730
7731 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7732 if (CurContext != Function)
7733 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007734
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007735 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007736 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007737
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007738 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007739 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007740 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007741 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7742 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7743 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7744 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7745 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7746 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007747 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007748 }
7749 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007750
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007751 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007752
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007753 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007754 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007755 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007756}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007757
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007758namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007759 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007760 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007761 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007762 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7763 Sema &S;
7764 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007765
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007766 public:
7767 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007768
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007769 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007770
7771 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7772 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007773 };
7774}
7775
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007776bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7777 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007778 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7779 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7780 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007781
7782 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007783}
7784
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007785bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007786 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7787 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7788 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007789 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7790 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007791 }
7792
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007793 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007794}
7795
7796void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7797 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007798 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007799}
7800
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007801/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7802/// of the program being compiled.
7803///
7804/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007805/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007806/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7807/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7808/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7809/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007810/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007811/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007812///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007813/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7814/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7815/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7816/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007817bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007818 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7819 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7820 case Unevaluated:
7821 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7822 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007823
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007824 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7825 Diag(Loc, PD);
7826 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007827
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007828 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7829 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7830 break;
7831 }
7832
7833 return false;
7834}
7835
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007836bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7837 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7838 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7839 return false;
7840
7841 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7842 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7843 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7844 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007845
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007846 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007847 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007848 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7849 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007850 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007851 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7852 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7853 return true;
7854
7855 return false;
7856}
7857
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007858// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7859// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7860void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7861 SourceLocation Loc;
7862
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007863 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7864
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007865 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7866 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007867 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007868 return;
7869
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007870 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7871 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7872 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7873 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7874
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007875 // self = [<foo> init...]
7876 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7877 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7878 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7879
7880 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7881 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7882 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7883 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7884 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007885
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007886 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7887 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7888 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7889 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7890 return;
7891
7892 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7893 } else {
7894 // Not an assignment.
7895 return;
7896 }
7897
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007898 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007899 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007900
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007901 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007902 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007903 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007904 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7905 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7906 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007907}
7908
7909bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7910 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7911
7912 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007913 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007914
7915 QualType T = E->getType();
7916
7917 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7918 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7919 return true;
7920 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7921 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7922 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7923 return true;
7924 }
7925 }
7926
7927 return false;
7928}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007929
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007930ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7931 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007932 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007933 return ExprError();
7934
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007935 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007936 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007937
7938 return Owned(Sub);
7939}